blob: 1f50b4e5c565abf72744b3dca7cce6776ab31755 [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall2d887082010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregore737f502010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000041
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +000059 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
60 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
61 // emit them now.
62 llvm::DenseMap<Decl *, llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 1> >::iterator
63 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
64 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
65 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second;
66 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I)
67 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second);
68
69 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
70 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't remove this
71 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
72 // diagnostics again.
73 Suppressed.clear();
74 }
75 }
76
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000077 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000078 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
79 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, DA->getMessage(), Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000080
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000081 // See if the decl is unavailable
Fariborz Jahanianc784dc12010-10-06 23:12:32 +000082 if (const UnavailableAttr *UA = D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
83 if (UA->getMessage().empty())
84 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
85 else
86 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000087 << D->getDeclName() << UA->getMessage();
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000088 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
89 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000090
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000091 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000092 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000093 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
94 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
95 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
96 return true;
97 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000098 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000099
Anders Carlsson2127ecc2010-10-22 23:37:08 +0000100 // Warn if this is used but marked unused.
101 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
102 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName();
103
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000104 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +0000105}
106
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000107/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000108/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000109/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
110///
111void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000112 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +0000113 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000114 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000115 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +0000116
117 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
118 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000119 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
120 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000121
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000122 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
123 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000124 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000125 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
126 int isMethod = 0;
127 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
128 // skip over named parameters.
129 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
130 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
131 if (nullPos)
132 --nullPos;
133 else
134 ++i;
135 }
136 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
137 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000138 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000139 // skip over named parameters.
140 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
141 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
142 if (nullPos)
143 --nullPos;
144 else
145 ++i;
146 }
147 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000148 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000149 // block or function pointer call.
150 QualType Ty = V->getType();
151 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000152 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000153 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
154 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000155 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
156 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
157 unsigned k;
158 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
159 if (nullPos)
160 --nullPos;
161 else
162 ++i;
163 }
164 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
165 }
166 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
167 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000168 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000169 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000170 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000171 return;
172
173 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000174 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000175 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000176 return;
177 }
178 int sentinel = i;
179 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
180 --sentinelPos;
181 ++i;
182 }
183 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
184 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000185 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000186 return;
187 }
188 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
189 ++i;
190 ++sentinel;
191 }
192 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000193 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
194 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
195 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ccd7252010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000196 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000197 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
198 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
199 return;
200
201 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
202 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
203
204 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
205 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000206}
207
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000208SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
209 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
210 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
211}
212
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
214// Standard Promotions and Conversions
215//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
216
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000217/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
218void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
219 QualType Ty = E->getType();
220 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
221
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000222 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000223 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000224 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000225 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
226 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
227 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
228 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
229 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
230 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
231 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000232 //
233 // C++ 4.2p1:
234 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
235 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
236 //
237 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
238 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000239 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000240 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000241 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000242}
243
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000244void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
245 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000246
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000247 QualType Ty = E->getType();
248 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
249 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
250 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
251 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
252 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
253 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
254 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
255 // rvalue is T
256 //
257 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000258 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
259 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000260 // type of the lvalue.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000262 }
263}
264
265
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000266/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000267/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000268/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
269/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
270/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
271Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
272 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
273 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000274
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000275 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
276 //
277 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
278 // unsigned int may be used:
279 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
280 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
281 // and unsigned int.
282 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
283 //
284 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
285 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
286 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
287 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000288 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
289 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000290 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000291 return Expr;
292 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000293 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000294 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000295 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000296 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000297 }
298
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000299 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000300 return Expr;
301}
302
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000303/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000304/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000305/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
306void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
307 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
308 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000309
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000310 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000311 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
312 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000313 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000314
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000315 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
316}
317
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000318/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
319/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
320/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
321/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000322bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
323 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000324 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000325
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000326 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
327 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
328 // etc.
329 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
330 return false;
331
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000332 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000333 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
334 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
335 << Expr->getType() << CT))
336 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000337
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000338 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000339 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000340 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
341 << Expr->getType() << CT))
342 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000343
344 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000345}
346
347
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000348/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
349/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000350/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000351/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
352/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
353/// GCC.
354QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
355 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000356 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000357 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000358
359 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000361 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000362 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000363 QualType lhs =
364 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000365 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000366 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000367
368 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
369 if (lhs == rhs)
370 return lhs;
371
372 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
373 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
374 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
375 return lhs;
376
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000377 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000378 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000379 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
380 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000381 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000382 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
383 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
384
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000385 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000386 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000387 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
388 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000389 return destType;
390}
391
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000392//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
393// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
394//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
395
396
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000397/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000398/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
399/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
400/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
401/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000402///
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000403ExprResult
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000404Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000405 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
406
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000407 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000408 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000409 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000410
411 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
412 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
413 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000414
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000415 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000416 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000417 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000418
419 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000420 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000421 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000422
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000423 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
424 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
425 // strings.
426 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000427 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000428 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000429
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000430 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000431 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
432 Literal.GetStringLength(),
433 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
434 &StringTokLocs[0],
435 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000436}
437
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000438/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
439/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
440/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
441/// for values inside the block or for globals).
442///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000443/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000444/// up-to-date.
445///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000446static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000447 ValueDecl *VD) {
448 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
449 // we wanted to.
450 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000453 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
454 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
455 return false;
456
457 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
458 // snapshot it.
459 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
460 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000461 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
462 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000463
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000464 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
465 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
466
467 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
468 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
469 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
470 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000471 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
472 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000473
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000474 if (!NextBlock)
475 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000476
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000477 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
478 // having a reference outside it.
479 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
480 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000481
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000482 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
483 // a snapshot as well.
484 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
485 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000486
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000487 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000488}
489
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000490
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000491ExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000492Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000493 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000494 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
495 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
496}
497
498/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000499ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000500Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
501 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
502 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000503 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000504 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000505 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000506 << D->getDeclName();
507 return ExprError();
508 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000509
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000510 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000511 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
512 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
513 // visible.
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000514 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000515 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000516 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
517 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000518 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
519 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000520 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000521 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000522 << D->getIdentifier();
523 return ExprError();
524 }
525 }
526 }
527 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000528
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000529 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000530
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000531 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
532 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
533 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000534 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000535}
536
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000537/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
538/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
539/// actual member.
540///
541/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
542/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
543/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
544/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
545/// we found.
546///
547/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
548/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
549/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
550VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
551 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000552 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
553 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
554 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
555
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000556 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000557 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
558 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
559 do {
560 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000561 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000562 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000563 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000564 else {
565 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
566 break;
567 }
568 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000569 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000570 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000571
572 return BaseObject;
573}
574
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000575ExprResult
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000576Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
577 FieldDecl *Field,
578 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
579 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
580 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000581 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000582 AnonFields);
583
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000584 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
585 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
586 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
587 // found via name lookup.
588 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000589 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 if (BaseObject) {
591 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
592 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000593 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000594 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Devang Patela2c21a22010-10-12 23:23:25 +0000595 Loc);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000596 BaseQuals
597 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000598 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
599 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
600 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
601 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
602 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000603 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000604 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
605 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
606 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 BaseQuals
608 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000609 } else {
610 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
611 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
612 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000613 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
614 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000615 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000616 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000617 = Context.getTagDeclType(
618 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
619 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000620 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000621 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
622 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
623 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000624 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000625 MD->getThisType(Context),
626 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000627 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
628 }
629 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000630 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
631 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000632 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000633 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000634 }
635
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000636 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000637 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
638 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000639 }
640
641 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
642 // anonymous struct/union.
643 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000644 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000645 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
646 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
647 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
648 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000649 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
650 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
651
652 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
653 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
654 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
655 ResultQuals.removeConst();
656
657 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
658 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
659
660 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
661 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
662
663 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
664 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
665 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
666
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000667 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000668 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000669 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000670 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
671 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000672 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000673 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000674 }
675
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000676 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000677}
678
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000679/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000680/// possibly a list of template arguments.
681///
682/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
683/// DecomposeTemplateName.
684///
685/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
686/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
687/// some way.
688static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
689 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
690 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000691 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000692 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
693 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
694 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
695 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
696
697 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
698 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
699 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
700 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
701 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
702
John McCall2b5289b2010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000703 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000704 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
705 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000706 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
707 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000708 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000709 TemplateArgs = 0;
710 }
711}
712
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000713/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
714/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
715/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000716static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000717 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
718 return false;
719
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000720 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
721 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
722 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
723 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
724 if (!BaseRT) return false;
725
726 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000727 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000728 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
729 return false;
730 }
731
732 return true;
733}
734
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000735/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
736/// the prospective base classes.
737static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
738 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
739 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000740 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000741 return false;
742
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000743 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000744 if (!RD) return false;
745 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
746
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000747 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
748 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
749 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
750 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
751 if (!BaseRT) return false;
752
753 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000754 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
755 return false;
756 }
757
758 return true;
759}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000760
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000761enum IMAKind {
762 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
763 IMA_Static,
764
765 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
766 IMA_Mixed,
767
768 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
769 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
770 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
771
772 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
773 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
774 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
775
776 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
777 IMA_Instance,
778
779 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
780 IMA_Unresolved,
781
782 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
783 /// context is not an instance method.
784 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
785
786 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
787 /// non-class context.
788 IMA_AnonymousMember,
789
790 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
791 /// context is not an instance method.
792 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
793
794 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
795 /// class.
796 IMA_Error_Unrelated
797};
798
799/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
800/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
801/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
802/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
803/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
804/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
805static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
806 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000807 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000808
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000809 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000810 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000811 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
812 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000813
814 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
815 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
816
817 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
818 bool hasNonInstance = false;
819 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
820 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000821 NamedDecl *D = *I;
822 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000823 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
824
825 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
826 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
827 // that's a special case.
828 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
829 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
830 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
831 }
832 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
833 }
834 else
835 hasNonInstance = true;
836 }
837
838 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
839 // member reference.
840 if (Classes.empty())
841 return IMA_Static;
842
843 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
844 // an implicit member reference.
845 if (isStaticContext)
846 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
847
848 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
849 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
850 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
851 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000852 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000853 Classes))
854 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
855
856 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
857}
858
859/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
860static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
861 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
862 const LookupResult &R) {
863 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
864 SourceRange Range(Loc);
865 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
866
867 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
868 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
869 if (MD->isStatic()) {
870 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
871 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
872 << Range << R.getLookupName();
873 return;
874 }
875 }
876
877 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
878 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
879 return;
880 }
881
882 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000883}
884
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000885/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
886///
887/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000888bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
889 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000890 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
891
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000892 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000893 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000894 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
895 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000896 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000897 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000898 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
899 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000900
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000901 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
902 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
903 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
904 // dependent name.
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000905 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000906 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000907 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
908 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
909
910 if (!R.empty()) {
911 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
912 R.suppressDiagnostics();
913
914 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
915 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
916 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
917 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
918
919 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
920 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
921 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000922 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000923 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
924 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000925 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000926 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000927 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000928 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
929 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
930 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
931 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
932 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
933 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
934 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
935 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
936 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
937 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
938 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
939 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
940 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
941 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000942 } else {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000943 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
944 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
945 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000946 }
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000947 } else {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000948 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000949 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000950
951 // Do we really want to note all of these?
952 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
953 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
954
955 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
956 return false;
957 }
Douglas Gregore26f0432010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000958
959 R.clear();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000960 }
961 }
962
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000963 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000964 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000965 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000966 if (!R.empty()) {
967 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
968 if (SS.isEmpty())
969 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
970 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
971 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
972 else
973 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
974 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
975 << SS.getRange()
976 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
977 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
978 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
979 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
980 << ND->getDeclName();
981
982 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
983 return false;
984 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000985
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000986 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
987 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
988 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
989 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
990 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
991 // to recover well anyway.
992 if (SS.isEmpty())
993 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
994 else
995 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
996 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
997 << SS.getRange();
998
999 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
1000 return true;
1001 }
1002 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001003 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001004 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001005 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001006 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001007 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001008 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001009 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1010 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001011 return true;
1012 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001013 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001014 }
1015
1016 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1017 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1018 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1019 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1020 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1021 << SS.getRange();
1022 return true;
1023 }
1024
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001025 // Give up, we can't recover.
1026 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1027 return true;
1028}
1029
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001030static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001031 IdentifierInfo *II,
1032 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001033 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1034 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1035 if (!IDecl)
1036 return 0;
1037 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1038 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1039 return 0;
1040 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1041 if (!property)
1042 return 0;
1043 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1044 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1045 return 0;
1046 return property;
1047}
1048
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001049static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001050 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001051 IdentifierInfo *II,
1052 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1053 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001054 bool LookForIvars;
1055 if (Lookup.empty())
1056 LookForIvars = true;
1057 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1058 LookForIvars = false;
1059 else
1060 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1061 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1062 if (!LookForIvars)
1063 return 0;
1064
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001065 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1066 if (!IDecl)
1067 return 0;
1068 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001069 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1070 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001071 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1072 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1073 if (!property)
1074 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian43e1b462010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001075 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II)) {
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001076 DynamicImplSeen =
1077 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
Fariborz Jahanian43e1b462010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001078 // property implementation has a designated ivar. No need to assume a new
1079 // one.
1080 if (!DynamicImplSeen && PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1081 return 0;
1082 }
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001083 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001084 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1085 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001086 NameLoc,
1087 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1088 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1089 (Expr *)0, true);
1090 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1091 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1092 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1093 return Ivar;
1094 }
1095 return 0;
1096}
1097
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001098ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001099 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1100 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1101 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1102 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001103 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1104 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1105
1106 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001107 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001108
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001109 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001110
1111 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001112 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001113 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001114 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001115
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001116 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001117 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001118 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001119
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001120 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1121 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001122 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1123 // (note: handled after lookup)
1124 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1125 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1126 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001127 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1128 // names a dependent type.
1129 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1130 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001131 bool DependentID = false;
1132 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1133 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1134 DependentID = true;
1135 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1136 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1137 if (DC) {
1138 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1139 return ExprError();
1140 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1141 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1142 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1143 } else {
1144 DependentID = true;
1145 }
1146 }
1147
1148 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001149 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001150 TemplateArgs);
1151 }
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001152 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001153 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001154 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001155 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001156 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1157 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1158 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1159 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1160 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001161 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1162 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1163 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001164 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001165 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001166 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001167
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001168 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1169 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001170 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001171 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001172 if (E.isInvalid())
1173 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001174
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001175 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1176 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001177 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1178 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001179 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001180 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1181 isAddressOfOperand);
1182 }
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001183 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1184 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001185 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001186 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001187
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001188 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1189 return ExprError();
1190
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001191 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1192 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001193 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001194
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001195 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001196 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001197 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1198 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1199 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1200 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1201 }
1202
1203 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1204 // call, diagnose the problem.
1205 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001206 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001207 return ExprError();
1208
1209 assert(!R.empty() &&
1210 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001211
1212 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1213 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001214 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001215 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1216 R.clear();
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001217 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001218 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1219 return move(E);
1220 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001221 }
1222 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001223
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001224 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1225 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1226
1227 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001228 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianb1d58e32010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001229 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1230 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001231 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1232 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1233 if (Property) {
1234 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1235 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001236 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001237 }
1238 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001239 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001240 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1241 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1242 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1243 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1244 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1245 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001246 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001247 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001248
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001249 QualType T = Func->getType();
1250 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001251 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001252 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1253 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001254 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001255 }
1256 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001257
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001258 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001259 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1260 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1261 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1262 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1263 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1264 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1265 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1266 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001267 //
1268 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1269 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1270 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1271 // non-static member function:
1272 //
1273 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1274 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1275 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1276 // member function call.
1277 //
1278 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1279 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1280 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1281 // instance method.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001282 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001283 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1284 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1285 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1286 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1287 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1288 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1289 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregore2248be2010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001290 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1291 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001292 else
1293 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1294
1295 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001296 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001297 }
1298
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001299 if (TemplateArgs)
1300 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001301
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001302 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1303}
1304
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001305/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001306ExprResult
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001307Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1308 LookupResult &R,
1309 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1310 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1311 case IMA_Instance:
1312 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1313
1314 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1315 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1316 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1317 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1318
1319 case IMA_Mixed:
1320 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1321 case IMA_Unresolved:
1322 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1323
1324 case IMA_Static:
1325 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1326 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1327 if (TemplateArgs)
1328 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1329 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1330
1331 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1332 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1333 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1334 return ExprError();
1335 }
1336
1337 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1338 return ExprError();
1339}
1340
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001341/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1342/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1343/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1344/// this path.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001345ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001346Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001347 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001348 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001349 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001350 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001351
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001352 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001353 return ExprError();
1354
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001355 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001356 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1357
1358 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1359 return ExprError();
1360
1361 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001362 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1363 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001364 return ExprError();
1365 }
1366
1367 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1368}
1369
1370/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1371/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1372/// additional lookup.
1373///
1374/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1375/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1376///
1377/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001378ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001379Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001380 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001381 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001382 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001383
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001384 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1385 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1386 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1387 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1388 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1389
1390 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1391 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1392 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001393 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001394
1395 bool LookForIvars;
1396 if (Lookup.empty())
1397 LookForIvars = true;
1398 else if (IsClassMethod)
1399 LookForIvars = false;
1400 else
1401 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1402 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001403 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001404 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001405 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001406 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1407 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1408 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1409 if (IsClassMethod)
1410 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1411 << IV->getDeclName());
1412
1413 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1414 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1415 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1416 return ExprError();
1417
1418 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1419 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1420 return ExprError();
1421
1422 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1423 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1424 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1425 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1426
1427 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1428 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1429 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1430 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001431 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001432 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001433 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregore45bb6a2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001434 SelfName, false, false);
1435 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1436 return ExprError();
1437
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001438 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1439 return Owned(new (Context)
1440 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1441 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1442 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001443 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001444 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001445 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001446 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1447 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1448 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1449 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1450 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1451 }
1452 }
1453
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001454 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1455 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1456 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1457 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1458 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1459 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1460 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1461 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1462 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1463 }
1464 }
1465 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001466 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1467 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001468}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001469
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001470/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1471///
1472/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1473///
1474/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1475/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1476/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1477/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1478///
1479/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1480/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1481/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1482/// the class declaring the member.
1483///
1484/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1485/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1486/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001487bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001488Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1489 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001490 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001491 NamedDecl *Member) {
1492 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1493 if (!RD)
1494 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001495
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001496 QualType DestRecordType;
1497 QualType DestType;
1498 QualType FromRecordType;
1499 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1500 bool PointerConversions = false;
1501 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1502 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001503
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001504 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1505 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1506 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1507 PointerConversions = true;
1508 } else {
1509 DestType = DestRecordType;
1510 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001511 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001512 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1513 if (Method->isStatic())
1514 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001515
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001516 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1517 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001518
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001519 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1520 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1521 PointerConversions = true;
1522 } else {
1523 FromRecordType = FromType;
1524 DestType = DestRecordType;
1525 }
1526 } else {
1527 // No conversion necessary.
1528 return false;
1529 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001530
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001531 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1532 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001533
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001534 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1535 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1536 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001537
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001538 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1539 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1540
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001541 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001542
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001543 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001544 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001545 // class name.
1546 //
1547 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1548 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1549 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1550 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1551 //
1552 // class Base { public: int x; };
1553 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1554 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1555 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1556 //
1557 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1558 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1559 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1560 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001561 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001562 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1563 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1564 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1565
1566 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1567
1568 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1569 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1570 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1571 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001572 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001573 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001574 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001575 return true;
1576
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001577 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001578 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001579 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1580 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001581
1582 FromType = QType;
1583 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1584
1585 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1586 // we're done.
1587 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1588 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001589 }
1590 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001591
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001592 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001593
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001594 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1595 // down to the using declaration's type.
1596 //
1597 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1598 // class ever has member declarations.
1599 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1600 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1601 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1602 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1603
1604 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1605 // conversion is non-trivial.
1606 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1607 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001608 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001609 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001610 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001611 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001612
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001613 QualType UType = URecordType;
1614 if (PointerConversions)
1615 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001616 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001617 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001618 FromType = UType;
1619 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1620 }
1621
1622 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1623 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1624 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001625 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001626
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001627 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001628 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1629 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001630 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001631 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001632
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001633 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001634 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001635 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001636}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001637
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001638/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001639static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001640 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001641 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001642 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1643 QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001644 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1645 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1646 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001647 if (SS.isSet()) {
1648 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1649 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001650 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001651
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001652 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001653 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1654 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001655}
1656
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001657/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1658/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1659/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1660/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001661ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001662Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1663 LookupResult &R,
1664 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1665 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001666 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1667
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001668 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001669
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001670 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1671 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001672 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001673 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001674 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001675 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001676 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001677
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001678 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1679 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001680 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1681 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001682 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1683 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001684 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1685 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1686 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1687 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001688 }
1689
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001690 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001691 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1692 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001693 SS,
1694 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1695 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001696}
1697
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001698bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001699 const LookupResult &R,
1700 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001701 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1702 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1703 return false;
1704
1705 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001706 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001707 return false;
1708
1709 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001710 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001711 return false;
1712
1713 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1714 // normal lookup:
1715 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1716 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1717
1718 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1719 // -- a declaration of a class member
1720 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1721 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001722 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001723 return false;
1724
1725 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1726 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1727 // using-declaration
1728 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1729 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1730 // turn off ADL anyway).
1731 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1732 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1733 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1734 return false;
1735
1736 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1737 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1738 // template
1739 // And also for builtin functions.
1740 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1741 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1742
1743 // But also builtin functions.
1744 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1745 return false;
1746 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1747 return false;
1748 }
1749
1750 return true;
1751}
1752
1753
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001754/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1755/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1756/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1757/// will in fact be used.
1758static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1759 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1760 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1761 return true;
1762 }
1763
1764 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1765 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1766 return true;
1767 }
1768
1769 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1770 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1771 return true;
1772 }
1773
1774 return false;
1775}
1776
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001777ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001778Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001779 LookupResult &R,
1780 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001781 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1782 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001783 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001784 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1785 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001786
1787 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1788 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1789 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001790 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1791 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001792 return ExprError();
1793
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001794 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1795 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1796 // we've picked a target.
1797 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1798
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001799 bool Dependent
1800 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001801 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001802 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001803 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001804 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001805 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1806 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001807
1808 return Owned(ULE);
1809}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001810
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001811
1812/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001813ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001814Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001815 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1816 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001817 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001818 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1819 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001820
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001821 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001822 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1823 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001824
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001825 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1826 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1827 // a template argument list.
1828 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1829 << Template << SS.getRange();
1830 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1831 return ExprError();
1832 }
1833
1834 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1835 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1836 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001837 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001838 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001839 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001840 return ExprError();
1841 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001842
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001843 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1844 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1845 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1846 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001847 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001848 return ExprError();
1849
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001850 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1851 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001852 return ExprError();
1853
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001854 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1855 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1856 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1857 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001858 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001859 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1860 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1861 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001862 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001863 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001864 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1865 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1866 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1867 return ExprError();
1868 }
1869
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001870 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001871 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1872 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1873 return ExprError();
1874 }
1875
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001876 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001877 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001878 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001879 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001880 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001881 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1882 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001883 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001884
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001885 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian52bc56a2010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001886 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001887 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1888 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian84ca0082010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001889 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001890 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1891 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1892 Expr *E = new (Context)
1893 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1894 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001895
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001896 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001897 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001898 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001899 SourceLocation(),
1900 Owned(E));
1901 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001902 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001903 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1904 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1905 }
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001906 }
1907 }
1908 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001909 }
1910 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1911 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001912
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001913 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1914 NameInfo, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001915}
1916
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001917ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001918 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001919 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001920
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001921 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001922 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001923 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1924 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1925 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001926 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001927
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001928 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1929 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001930
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001931 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanianeb024ac2010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001932 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1933 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001934 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001935 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001936 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001937 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001938
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001939 QualType ResTy;
1940 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1941 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1942 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001943 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001944
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001945 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001946 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001947 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1948 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001949 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001950}
1951
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001952ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001953 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001954 bool Invalid = false;
1955 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1956 if (Invalid)
1957 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001958
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001959 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1960 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001961 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001962 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001963
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001964 QualType Ty;
1965 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1966 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1967 else if (Literal.isWide())
1968 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001969 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1970 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001971 else
1972 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001973
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001974 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1975 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001976 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001977}
1978
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001979ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001980 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001981 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1982 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001983 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001984 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00001985 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001986 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001987 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001988
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001989 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001990 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1991 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001992 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001993
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001994 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001995 bool Invalid = false;
1996 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1997 if (Invalid)
1998 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001999
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002000 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002001 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
2002 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002003 return ExprError();
2004
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002005 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002006
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002007 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002008 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002009 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002010 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002011 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002012 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002013 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00002014 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002015
2016 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
2017
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002018 using llvm::APFloat;
2019 APFloat Val(Format);
2020
2021 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00002022
2023 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
2024 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
2025 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
2026 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002027 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002028 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002029 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002030 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002031 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2032 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002033 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002034 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2035 }
2036
2037 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2038 << Ty
2039 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2040 }
2041
2042 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002043 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002044
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002045 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002046 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002047 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002048 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002049
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002050 // long long is a C99 feature.
2051 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002052 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002053 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2054
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002055 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002056 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002057
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002058 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2059 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2060 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002061 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2062 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002063 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002064 } else {
2065 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2066 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002067
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002068 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2069 // be an unsigned int.
2070 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2071
2072 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002073 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002074 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2075 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002076 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002077
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002078 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2079 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2080 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2081 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002082 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002083 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002084 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002085 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002086 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002087 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002088
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002089 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002090 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002091 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002092
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002093 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2094 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2095 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2096 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002097 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002098 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002099 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002100 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002101 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002102 }
2103
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002104 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002105 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002106 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002107
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002108 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2109 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2110 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2111 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002112 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002113 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002114 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002115 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002116 }
2117 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002118
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002119 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2120 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002121 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002122 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002123 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002124 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002125 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002126
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002127 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2128 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002129 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002130 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002131 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002132
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002133 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2134 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002135 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002136 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002137
2138 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002139}
2140
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002141ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002142 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002143 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002144 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002145}
2146
2147/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2148/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002149bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002150 SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002151 SourceRange ExprRange,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002152 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002153 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2154 return false;
2155
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002156 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2157 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2158 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2159 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2160 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2161 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2162
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002163 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002164 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002165 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002166 if (isSizeof)
2167 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2168 return false;
2169 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002170
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002171 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002172 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002173 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2174 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002175 return false;
2176 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002177
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002178 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002179 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2180 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002181 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002182
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002183 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002184 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002185 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002186 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2187 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002188 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002189
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002190 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002191}
2192
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002193static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2194 SourceRange ExprRange) {
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002195 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002196
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002197 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002198 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2199 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002200
2201 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2202 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2203 return false;
2204
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002205 if (E->getBitField()) {
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002206 S. Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002207 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002208 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002209
2210 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2211 // bit-field.
2212 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002213 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002214 return false;
2215
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002216 return S.CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002217}
2218
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002219/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002220ExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002221Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002222 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002223 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002224 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002225 return ExprError();
2226
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002227 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002228
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002229 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2230 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2231 return ExprError();
2232
2233 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002234 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002235 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2236 R.getEnd()));
2237}
2238
2239/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2240/// operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002241ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002242Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002243 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2244 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2245 bool isInvalid = false;
2246 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2247 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2248 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002249 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002250 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002251 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2252 isInvalid = true;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002253 } else if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
2254 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E, OpLoc);
2255 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2256 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(PE.take(), OpLoc, isSizeOf, R);
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002257 } else {
2258 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2259 }
2260
2261 if (isInvalid)
2262 return ExprError();
2263
2264 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2265 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2266 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2267 R.getEnd()));
2268}
2269
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002270/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2271/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2272/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002273ExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002274Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2275 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002276 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002277 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002278
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002279 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002280 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002281 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002282 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002283 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002284
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002285 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002286 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002287 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2288
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002289 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002290}
2291
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002292QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002293 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2294 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002295
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002296 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002297 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002298 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002299
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002300 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2301 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2302 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002303
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002304 // Test for placeholders.
2305 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(V, Loc);
2306 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
2307 if (PR.take() != V) {
2308 V = PR.take();
2309 return CheckRealImagOperand(V, Loc, isReal);
2310 }
2311
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002312 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002313 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2314 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002315 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002316}
2317
2318
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002319
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002320ExprResult
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002321Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002322 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002323 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002324 switch (Kind) {
2325 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002326 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2327 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002328 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002329
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002330 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002331}
2332
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002333ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002334Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2335 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002336 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002337 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002338 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2339 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002340
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002341 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002342
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002343 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002344 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002345 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2346 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2347 }
2348
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002349 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002350 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002351 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2352 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2353 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002354 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002355 }
2356
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002357 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002358}
2359
2360
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002361ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002362Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2363 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2364 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2365 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002366
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002367 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002368 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2369 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2370 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002371
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002372 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002373
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002374 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002375 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002376 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002377 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002378 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2379 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002380 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2381 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2382 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2383 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002384 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002385 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2386 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002387 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002388 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002389 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002390 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2391 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002392 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002393 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002394 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002395 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2396 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2397 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002398 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002399 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002400 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2401 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2402 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2403 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002404 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002405 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002406 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002407
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002408 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2409 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002410 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2411 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002412 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002413 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2414 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2415 // force the promotion here.
2416 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2417 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002418 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002419 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002420 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2421
2422 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2423 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002424 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002425 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2426 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2427 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2428 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002429 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002430 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002431 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2432
2433 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2434 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002435 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002436 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002437 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2438 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002439 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002440 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002441 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002442 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2443 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002444
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002445 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002446 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2447 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002448 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2449
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002450 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002451 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2452 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002453 // incomplete types are not object types.
2454 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2455 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2456 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2457 return ExprError();
2458 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002459
Abramo Bagnara46358452010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002460 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2461 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2462 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2463 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2464 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002465 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002466 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2467 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002468 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002469
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002470 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002471 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002472 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2473 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2474 return ExprError();
2475 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002476
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002477 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002478 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002479}
2480
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002481QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002482CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002483 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002484 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002485 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2486 // see FIXME there.
2487 //
2488 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2489 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002490 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002491
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002492 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002493 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002494
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002495 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002496 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2497 // to be selected.
2498 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002499
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002500 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2501 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002502 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002503
2504 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2505 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002506 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002507 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2508 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002509 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002510 do
2511 compStr++;
2512 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002513 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002514 do
2515 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002516 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002517 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002518
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002519 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002520 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2521 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002522 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramer476d8b82010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002523 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002524 return QualType();
2525 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002526
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002527 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2528 // operates on.
2529 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002530 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002531
2532 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002533 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002534
2535 while (*compStr) {
2536 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2537 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2538 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2539 return QualType();
2540 }
2541 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002542 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002543
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002544 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002545 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002546 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002547 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002548 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002549 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002550 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002551 if (HexSwizzle)
2552 CompSize--;
2553
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002554 if (CompSize == 1)
2555 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002556
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002557 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002558 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002559 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2560 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2561 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2562 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002563 }
2564 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002565}
2566
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002567static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002568 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002569 const Selector &Sel,
2570 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002571 if (Member)
2572 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
2573 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002574 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002575 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002576
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002577 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2578 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002579 if (Decl *D = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2580 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002581 return D;
2582 }
2583 return 0;
2584}
2585
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002586static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
2587 IdentifierInfo *Member,
2588 const Selector &Sel,
2589 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002590 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2591 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002592 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002593 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002594 if (Member)
2595 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
2596 GDecl = PD;
2597 break;
2598 }
2599 // Also must look for a getter or setter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002600 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002601 GDecl = OMD;
2602 break;
2603 }
2604 }
2605 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002606 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002607 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2608 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002609 GDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2610 Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002611 if (GDecl)
2612 return GDecl;
2613 }
2614 }
2615 return GDecl;
2616}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002617
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002618ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002619Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002620 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002621 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2622 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002623 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002624 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002625 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2626 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2627 //
2628 // T* t;
2629 // t.f;
2630 //
2631 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2632 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2633 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2634 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002635 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002636 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2637 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002638 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002639 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002640 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002641 return ExprError();
2642 }
2643 }
2644
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002645 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2646 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002647 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002648
2649 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2650 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002651 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002652 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002653 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002654 SS.getRange(),
2655 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002656 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002657}
2658
2659/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2660/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2661/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2662static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2663 Expr *BaseExpr,
2664 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002665 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002666 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002667 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2668 // diagnostics.
2669 if (!BaseExpr)
2670 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002671
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002672 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2673 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002674}
2675
2676// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2677// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2678// type. The restriction here is:
2679//
2680// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2681// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2682// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2683//
2684// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2685// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2686// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2687// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2688bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2689 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002690 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002691 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002692 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2693 if (!BaseRT) {
2694 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2695 // dependent.
2696 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2697 return false;
2698 }
2699 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002700
2701 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002702 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2703 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002704 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002705 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002706
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002707 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002708 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2709 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2710 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002711
Douglas Gregor9d4bb942010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002712 if (!DC->isRecord())
2713 continue;
2714
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002715 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002716 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002717
2718 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2719 return false;
2720 }
2721
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002722 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002723 return true;
2724}
2725
2726static bool
2727LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2728 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002729 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2730 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002731 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2732 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002733 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002734 << BaseRange))
2735 return true;
2736
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002737 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2738 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2739 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2740
2741 bool MOUS;
2742 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2743 return false;
2744 }
2745
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002746 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2747 if (SS.isSet()) {
2748 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2749 // nested-name-specifier.
2750 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2751
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002752 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002753 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2754 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2755 return true;
2756 }
2757
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002758 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002759
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002760 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2761 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2762 << DC << SS.getRange();
2763 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002764 }
2765 }
2766
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002767 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2768 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002769
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002770 if (!R.empty())
2771 return false;
2772
2773 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2774 // for typos.
2775 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002776 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002777 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002778 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2779 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2780 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002781 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2782 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002783 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2784 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2785 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002786 return false;
2787 } else {
2788 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002789 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002790 }
2791
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002792 return false;
2793}
2794
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002795ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002796Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002797 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002798 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002799 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002800 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002801 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002802 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2803 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002804 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002805 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2806 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002807 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002808
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002809 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002810
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002811 // Implicit member accesses.
2812 if (!Base) {
2813 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2814 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2815 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2816 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002817 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002818 return ExprError();
2819
2820 // Explicit member accesses.
2821 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002822 ExprResult Result =
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002823 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002824 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002825
2826 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2827 Owned(Base);
2828 return ExprError();
2829 }
2830
2831 if (Result.get())
2832 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002833
2834 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2835 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002836 }
2837
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002838 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002839 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2840 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002841}
2842
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002843ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002844Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002845 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2846 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002847 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002848 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002849 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2850 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002851 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002852 if (IsArrow) {
2853 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2854 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2855 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002856 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002857
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002858 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002859 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2860 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2861 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002862
2863 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002864 return ExprError();
2865
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002866 if (R.empty()) {
2867 // Rederive where we looked up.
2868 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2869 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2870 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002871
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002872 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002873 << MemberName << DC
2874 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002875 return ExprError();
2876 }
2877
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002878 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2879 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2880 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2881 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2882 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2883 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2884 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2885 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2886 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2887 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002888 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002889 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002890 return ExprError();
2891
2892 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2893 // result.
2894 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002895 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002896 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002897 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002898 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002899
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002900 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2901 // pick a member.
2902 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2903
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002904 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2905 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2906 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002907 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2908 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002909 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002910 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002911 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002912
2913 return Owned(MemExpr);
2914 }
2915
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002916 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002917 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002918 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2919
2920 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2921
2922 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2923 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2924 // error cases.
2925 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2926 return ExprError();
2927
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002928 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2929 if (!BaseExpr) {
2930 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002931 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002932 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002933
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002934 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2935 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2936 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2937 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002938 }
2939
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002940 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2941 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2942 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2943 // explicitly qualified.
2944 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2945 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2946 }
2947
2948 // Check the use of this member.
2949 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2950 Owned(BaseExpr);
2951 return ExprError();
2952 }
2953
2954 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2955 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2956 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002957 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2958 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002959 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2960 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2961
2962 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2963 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2964 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2965 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2966 else {
2967 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2968 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2969 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2970
2971 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2972 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2973
2974 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2975 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2976 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2977 }
2978
2979 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002980 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002981 return ExprError();
2982 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002983 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2984 MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002985 }
2986
2987 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2988 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2989 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002990 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002991 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2992 }
2993
2994 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2995 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2996 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002997 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002998 MemberFn->getType()));
2999 }
3000
3001 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3002 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3003 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003004 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
3005 Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003006 }
3007
3008 Owned(BaseExpr);
3009
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003010 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003011 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003012 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003013 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
3014 else
3015 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
3016 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003017
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003018 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
3019 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003020 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003021 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003022}
3023
3024/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
3025/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
3026/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
3027/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
3028/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
3029/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
3030/// an ordinary member expression.
3031///
3032/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
3033/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003034ExprResult
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003035Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003036 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003037 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003038 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003039 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003040
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003041 // Perform default conversions.
3042 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003043
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003044 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003045 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3046
3047 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3048 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003049
3050 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003051 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003052 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3053 // call, and continue on.
3054 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3055 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3056 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3057 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3058 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003059 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3060 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003061 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3062 ->isRecordType()))) {
3063 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
Nick Lewycky3d6c45d2010-10-15 21:43:24 +00003064 Diag(BaseExpr->getExprLoc(), diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003065 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003066 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003067
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003068 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003069 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregorf918b832010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003070 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003071 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003072 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003073
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003074 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3075 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3076 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3077 }
3078 }
3079 }
3080
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003081 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3082 // use that.
3083 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003084 if (IsArrow) {
3085 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3086 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3087 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003088 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003089 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003090 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3091 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003092 }
3093 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003094 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3095 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3096 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3097 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003098 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003099 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003100 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003101
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003102 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3103 // use that.
3104 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3105 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3106 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3107 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3108 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003109 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003110 }
3111 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003112
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003113 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003114
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003115 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003116 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003117 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3118 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3119 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3120 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3121 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3122 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3123 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3124 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3125 // Check the use of this method.
3126 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3127 return ExprError();
3128 }
3129 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3130 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3131 Selector SetterSel =
3132 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3133 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3134 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3135 if (!Setter) {
3136 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3137 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003138 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003139 }
3140 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3141 if (!Setter)
3142 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003143
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003144 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3145 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003146
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003147 if (Getter || Setter) {
3148 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003149
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003150 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003151 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003152 else
3153 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3154 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3155 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003156 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003157 PType,
3158 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3159 }
3160 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3161 << MemberName << BaseType);
3162 }
3163 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003164
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003165 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3166 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3167 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003168 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003169 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003170
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003171 if (IsArrow) {
3172 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003173 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003174 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3175 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003176 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3177 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3178 // struct MyRecord foo;
3179 // foo->bar
3180 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3181 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3182 // by now.
3183 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3184 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003185 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003186 IsArrow = false;
3187 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003188 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3189 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3190 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003191 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003192 } else {
3193 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3194 // type *foo;
3195 // foo.bar
3196 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3197 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3198 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3199 // the appropriate pointer type
3200 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3201 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3202 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3203 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3204 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003205 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003206 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3207 IsArrow = true;
3208 }
3209 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003210 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003211
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003212 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003213 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003214 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003215 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003216 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003217 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003218 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003219
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003220 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3221 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003222 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003223 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003224 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003225 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3226 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3227 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3228 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003229 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3230
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003231 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003232 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003233
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003234 if (!IV) {
3235 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3236 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3237 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor9a632ea2010-10-20 03:06:34 +00003238 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false,
3239 IsArrow? CTC_ObjCIvarLookup
3240 : CTC_ObjCPropertyLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003241 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003242 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003243 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3244 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003245 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3246 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003247 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003248 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003249 } else {
3250 Res.clear();
3251 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003252 }
3253 }
3254
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003255 if (IV) {
3256 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3257 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3258 // error cases.
3259 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3260 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003261
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003262 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3263 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3264 return ExprError();
3265 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3266 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3267 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3268 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3269 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3270 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3271 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3272 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3273 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3274 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3275 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3276 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003277 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003278 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003279 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3280 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003281 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003282 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3283 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003284
3285 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3286 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003287 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003288 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003289 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003290 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3291 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003292 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003293 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003294 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003295
3296 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3297 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003298 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003299 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003300 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003301 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003302 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003303 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003304 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003305 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003306 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3307 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003308 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003309 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003310
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003311 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003312 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003313 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel,
3314 Context)) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003315 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3316 // Check the use of this declaration
3317 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3318 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003319
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003320 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003321 MemberLoc,
3322 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003323 }
3324 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3325 // Check the use of this method.
3326 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3327 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003328 Selector SetterSel =
3329 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3330 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3331 ObjCMethodDecl *SMD = 0;
3332 if (Decl *SDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, /*Property id*/0,
3333 SetterSel, Context))
3334 SMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(SDecl);
3335 QualType PType = OMD->getSendResultType();
3336 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(OMD, PType,
3337 SMD,
3338 MemberLoc,
3339 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003340 }
3341 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003342
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003343 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003344 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003345 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003346
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003347 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3348 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003349 if (!IsArrow)
3350 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3351 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003352 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc,
3353 SourceLocation(), QualType(), false);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003354
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003355 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003356 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003357 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3358 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003359 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003360 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003361 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003362
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003363 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003364 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003365 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003366 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3367 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003368 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003369 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003370 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003371 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003372
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003373 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3374 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3375
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003376 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003377}
3378
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003379/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3380/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3381/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3382/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3383/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3384///
3385/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3386/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3387/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3388/// only be called
3389/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3390/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3391/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003392ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003393 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3394 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003395 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003396 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003397 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003398 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3399 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3400 return ExprError();
3401
3402 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3403
3404 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003405 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003406 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3407 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003408 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003409
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003410 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003411 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3412
3413 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3414 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3415 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3416
3417 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003418 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003419 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3420 Base = Result.take();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003421
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003422 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3423 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003424 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003425 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3426 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003427 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003428 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003429 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003430 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3431 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003432
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003433 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3434 Owned(Base);
3435 return ExprError();
3436 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003437
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003438 if (Result.get()) {
3439 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3440 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3441 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3442 // call now.
3443 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3444 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003445 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003446
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003447 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003448 }
3449
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003450 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003451 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3452 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003453 }
3454
3455 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003456}
3457
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003458ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003459 FunctionDecl *FD,
3460 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3461 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003462 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003463 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3464 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003465 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003466 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003467 return ExprError();
3468 }
3469
3470 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3471 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003472
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003473 // Instantiate the expression.
3474 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3475 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003476
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003477 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3478 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3479 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3480 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003481
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003482 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3483 if (Result.isInvalid())
3484 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003485
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003486 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3487 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003488 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003489 InitializationKind Kind
3490 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3491 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3492 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003493
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003494 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3495 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3496 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3497 if (Result.isInvalid())
3498 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003499
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003500 // Build the default argument expression.
3501 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3502 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003503 }
3504
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003505 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3506 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3507 // be properly destroyed.
3508 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3509 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003510 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3511 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3512 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3513 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3514 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3515 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003516
3517 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003518 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3519 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003520 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003521 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003522}
3523
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003524/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3525/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3526/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3527/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3528/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3529/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003530bool
3531Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003532 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003533 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003534 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3535 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003536 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003537 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3538 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003539 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003540
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003541 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3542 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3543 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3544 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3545 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003546 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003547 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003548 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003549 }
3550
3551 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3552 // them.
3553 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3554 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3555 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3556 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003557 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003558 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003559 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3560 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3561 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003562 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003563 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003564 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003565 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003566 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003567 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003568 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3569 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3570 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3571 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3572 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003573 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003574 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003575 if (Invalid)
3576 return true;
3577 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3578 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3579 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003580
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003581 return false;
3582}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003583
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003584bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3585 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3586 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3587 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3588 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3589 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003590 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003591 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3592 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3593 bool Invalid = false;
3594 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3595 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3596 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3597 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003598 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003599 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003600 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003601
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003602 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003603 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3604 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003605
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003606 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3607 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003608 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003609 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003610 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003611
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003612 // Pass the argument
3613 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3614 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3615 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003616
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003617 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003618 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
3619 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003620 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003621 SourceLocation(),
3622 Owned(Arg));
3623 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3624 return true;
3625
3626 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003627 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003628 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003629
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003630 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003631 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003632 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3633 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003634
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003635 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003636 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003637 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003638 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003639
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003640 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003641 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003642 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003643 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003644 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003645 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003646 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003647 }
3648 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003649 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003650}
3651
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003652/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003653/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3654/// locations.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003655ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003656Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003657 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003658 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003659
3660 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003661 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003662 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3663 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003664
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003665 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003666
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003667 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003668 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3669 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3670 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3671 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3672 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003673 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003674 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3675 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003676
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003677 NumArgs = 0;
3678 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003679
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003680 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3681 RParenLoc));
3682 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003683
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003684 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003685 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003686 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3687 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003688 bool Dependent = false;
3689 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3690 Dependent = true;
3691 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3692 Dependent = true;
3693
3694 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003695 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003696 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3697
3698 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3699 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3700 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003701 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003702
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003703 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3704
3705 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3706 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3707 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3708 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3709 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3710 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3711 // method template.
3712 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003713 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3714 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003715 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003716
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003717 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003718 RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003719 }
3720
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003721 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003722 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003723 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003724 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003725 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003726 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003727 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003728
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003729 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003730 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003731 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3732 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003733 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3734 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003735 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003736
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003737 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3738 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3739 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3740 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003741
3742 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3743 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003744 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003745 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003746
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003747 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003748 RParenLoc))
3749 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003750
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003751 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003752 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003753 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003754 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3755 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003756 }
3757 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003758 }
3759
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003760 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003761 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003762 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003763
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003764 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003765 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3766 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003767 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003768 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003769 }
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003770
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003771 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
Douglas Gregord8f0ade2010-10-25 20:48:33 +00003772 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn))
3773 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf)
3774 NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
3775
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003776 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3777 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3778
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003779 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3780}
3781
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003782/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3783/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003784/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3785/// block-pointer type.
3786///
3787/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003788ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003789Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3790 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3791 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3792 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3793 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3794
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003795 // Promote the function operand.
3796 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3797
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003798 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3799 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003800 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3801 Args, NumArgs,
3802 Context.BoolTy,
3803 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003804
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003805 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3806 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3807 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3808 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003809 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003810 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003811 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3812 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003813 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003814 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003815 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003816 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003817 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003818 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003819 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3820 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3821
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003822 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003823 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003824 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003825 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003826 return ExprError();
3827
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003828 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003829 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003830
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003831 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003832 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003833 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003834 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003835 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003836 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003837
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003838 if (FDecl) {
3839 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3840 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3841 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis06a54a32010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003842 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003843 const FunctionProtoType *Proto
3844 = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3845 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size()))
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003846 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3847 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003848 }
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003849
3850 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have
3851 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype.
3852 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype())
3853 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003854 }
3855
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003856 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003857 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3858 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003859
3860 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumArgs()) {
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003861 InitializedEntity Entity
3862 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
3863 Proto->getArgType(i));
3864 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3865 SourceLocation(),
3866 Owned(Arg));
3867 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3868 return true;
3869
3870 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
3871
3872 } else {
3873 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003874 }
3875
Douglas Gregor0700bbf2010-10-26 05:45:40 +00003876 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3877 Arg->getType(),
3878 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3879 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
3880 return ExprError();
3881
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003882 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003883 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003884 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003885
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003886 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3887 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003888 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3889 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003890
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003891 // Check for sentinels
3892 if (NDecl)
3893 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003894
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003895 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003896 if (FDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003897 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003898 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003899
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003900 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003901 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003902 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003903 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003904 return ExprError();
3905 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003906
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003907 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003908}
3909
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003910ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003911Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003912 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003913 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003914 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003915 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003916
3917 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3918 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3919 if (!TInfo)
3920 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3921
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003922 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003923}
3924
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003925ExprResult
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003926Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003927 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003928 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003929
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003930 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003931 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003932 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3933 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003934 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3935 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003936 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003937 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003938 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003939 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003940
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003941 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003942 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003943 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003944 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003945 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003946 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003947 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCallca0408f2010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003948 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003949 &literalType);
3950 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003951 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003952 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003953
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003954 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003955 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003956 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003957 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003958 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003959
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003960 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003961 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003962}
3963
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003964ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003965Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003966 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3967 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003968 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003969
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003970 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003971 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003972
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003973 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3974 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003975 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003976 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003977}
3978
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003979static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003980 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003981 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003982 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003983
3984 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3985 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003986 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003987 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
3988 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003989 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003990 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003991 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003992
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003993 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3994 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003995 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003996 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003997 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003998 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003999 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004000 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004001
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004002 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
4003 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004004 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004005 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004006 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004007 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004008
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004009 // FIXME: Assert here.
4010 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004011 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004012}
4013
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004014/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00004015bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004016 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004017 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00004018 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004019 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004020 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
4021 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004022
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004023 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004024
4025 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
4026 // type needs to be scalar.
4027 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
4028 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004029 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004030 return false;
4031 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004032
Eli Friedman8d438082010-07-17 20:43:49 +00004033 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
4034 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
4035 return true;
4036
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004037 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004038 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004039 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
4040 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004041 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004042 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
4043 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004044 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004045 return false;
4046 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004047
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004048 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004049 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004050 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004051 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004052 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004053 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004054 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara8c4bfe52010-10-07 21:20:44 +00004055 castExpr->getType()) &&
4056 !Field->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004057 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
4058 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4059 break;
4060 }
4061 }
4062 if (Field == FieldEnd)
4063 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
4064 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004065 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004066 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004067 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004068
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004069 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
4070 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4071 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4072 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004073
4074 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004075 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004076 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4077 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004078 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004079 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004080
4081 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004082 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004083
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004084 if (castType->isVectorType())
4085 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4086 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4087 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4088
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004089 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4090 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004091
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004092 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004093 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004094 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004095 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004096 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4097 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4098 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4099 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004100 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004101 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4102 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4103 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004104 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004105
4106 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004107
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004108 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004109 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4110
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004111 return false;
4112}
4113
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004114bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004115 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004116 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004117
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004118 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004119 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004120 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004121 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004122 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004123 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004124 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004125 } else
4126 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004127 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004128 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004129
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004130 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004131 return false;
4132}
4133
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004134bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004135 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004136 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004137
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004138 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004139
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004140 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4141 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004142 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4143 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4144 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4145 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004146 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004147 return false;
4148 }
4149
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004150 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004151 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4152 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004153 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4154 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4155 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4156 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004157
4158 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4159 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4160 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004161
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004162 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004163 return false;
4164}
4165
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004166ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004167Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004168 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4169 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004170 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004171
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004172 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4173 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4174 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004175 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004176
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004177 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4178 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004179 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004180 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004181
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004182 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004183}
4184
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004185ExprResult
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004186Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004187 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004188 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004189 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004190 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004191 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004192 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004193
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004194 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004195 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004196 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4197 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004198}
4199
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004200/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4201/// of comma binary operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004202ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004203Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004204 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4205 if (!E)
4206 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004207
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004208 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004209
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004210 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004211 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4212 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004213
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004214 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4215
4216 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004217}
4218
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004219ExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004220Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004221 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004222 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004223 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004224 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004225 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004226
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004227 // Check for an altivec literal,
4228 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004229 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4230 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4231 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4232 return ExprError();
4233 }
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004234 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4235 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4236 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4237 }
4238 else
4239 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4240 }
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004241
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004242 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4243 // then handle it as such.
4244 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004245 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4246 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4247 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4248
4249 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4250 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004251 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4252 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004253 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4254 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004255 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004256 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004257 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004258 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004259 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004260 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4261 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004262 }
4263}
4264
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004265ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004266 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004267 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004268 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004269 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4270 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004271 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4272 Expr *expr;
4273 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4274 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4275 else
4276 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004277 return Owned(expr);
4278}
4279
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004280/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4281/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004282/// C99 6.5.15
4283QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004284 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004285 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004286 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4287 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004288 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004289
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004290 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004291 if (SAVE) {
4292 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4293 }
4294 else
4295 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004296 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4297 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4298 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4299 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004300
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004301 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004302 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004303 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4304 // Throw an error if its not either.
4305 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4306 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4307 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4308 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4309 << CondTy;
4310 return QualType();
4311 }
4312 }
4313 else {
4314 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4315 << CondTy;
4316 return QualType();
4317 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004318 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004319
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004320 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004321 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4322 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004323
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004324 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4325 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4326 // built in select.
4327 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4328 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4329 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4330 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4331 << CondTy;
4332 return QualType();
4333 }
4334 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4335 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4336 << CondTy;
4337 return QualType();
4338 }
4339 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4340 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4341 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4342 }
4343
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004344 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4345 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004346 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4347 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4348 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004349 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004350
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004351 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4352 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004353 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4354 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004355 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004356 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004357 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004358 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004359 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004360 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004361
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004362 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004363 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004364 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4365 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4366 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4367 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4368 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4369 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4370 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004371 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4372 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004373 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004374 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004375 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4376 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004377 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004378 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004379 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004380 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004381 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004382 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004383 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004384 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004385 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004386 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004387 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004388
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004389 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4390 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4391 QuestionLoc);
4392 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4393 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004394
4395
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004396 // Handle block pointer types.
4397 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4398 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4399 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4400 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004401 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4402 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004403 return destType;
4404 }
4405 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004406 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004407 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004408 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004409 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4410 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4411 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004412 return LHSTy;
4413 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004414 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004415 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4416 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004417
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004418 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4419 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004420 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004421 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004422 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4423 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4424 // to get a consistent AST.
4425 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004426 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4427 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004428 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004429 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004430 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004431 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4432 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004433 return LHSTy;
4434 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004435
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004436 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4437 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4438 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004439 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4440 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004441
4442 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4443 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4444 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004445 QualType destPointee
4446 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004447 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004448 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004449 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004450 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004451 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004452 return destType;
4453 }
4454 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004455 QualType destPointee
4456 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004457 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004458 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004459 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004460 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004461 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004462 return destType;
4463 }
4464
4465 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4466 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4467 return LHSTy;
4468 }
4469 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4470 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4471 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4472 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4473 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4474 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4475 // to get a consistent AST.
4476 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004477 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4478 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004479 return incompatTy;
4480 }
4481 // The pointer types are compatible.
4482 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4483 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4484 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4485 // type.
4486 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4487 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004488 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4489 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004490 return LHSTy;
4491 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004492
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004493 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4494 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4495 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4496 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004497 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004498 return RHSTy;
4499 }
4500 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4501 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4502 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004503 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004504 return LHSTy;
4505 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004506
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004507 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004508 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4509 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004510 return QualType();
4511}
4512
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004513/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4514/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4515QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4516 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4517 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4518 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004519
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004520 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4521 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4522 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4523 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4524 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004525 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004526 return LHSTy;
4527 }
4528 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4529 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004530 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004531 return RHSTy;
4532 }
4533 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4534 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4535 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004536 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004537 return LHSTy;
4538 }
4539 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4540 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004541 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004542 return RHSTy;
4543 }
4544 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4545 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4546 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004547 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004548 return LHSTy;
4549 }
4550 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4551 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004552 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004553 return RHSTy;
4554 }
4555 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4556 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004557
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004558 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4559 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4560 return LHSTy;
4561 }
4562 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4563 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4564 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004565
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004566 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4567 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4568 // type. This allows
4569 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4570 // where B is a subclass of A.
4571 //
4572 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4573 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4574 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4575 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004576
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004577 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4578 // It could return the composite type.
4579 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4580 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4581 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4582 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4583 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4584 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4585 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4586 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4587 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4588 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4589 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4590 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4591 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4592 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004593 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004594 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4595 ;
4596 else {
4597 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4598 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4599 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4600 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004601 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4602 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004603 return incompatTy;
4604 }
4605 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004606 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4607 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004608 return compositeType;
4609 }
4610 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4611 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4612 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4613 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4614 QualType destPointee
4615 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4616 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4617 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004618 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004619 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004620 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004621 return destType;
4622 }
4623 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4624 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4625 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4626 QualType destPointee
4627 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4628 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4629 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004630 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004631 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004632 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004633 return destType;
4634 }
4635 return QualType();
4636}
4637
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004638/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004639/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004640ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004641 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004642 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4643 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004644 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4645 // was the condition.
4646 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004647 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
4648 if (isLHSNull) {
4649 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
4650 }
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004651
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004652 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
4653 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004654 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004655 return ExprError();
4656
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004657 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004658 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
4659 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
4660 result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004661}
4662
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004663// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004664// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004665// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4666// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4667// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004668Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004669Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
4670 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004671
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004672 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4673 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4674 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4675 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4676 return Compatible;
4677 }
4678
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004679 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004680 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4681 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004682
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004683 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004684 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4685 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004686
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004687 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004688
4689 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4690 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4691 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004692 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004693 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004694 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004695
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004696 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4697 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004698 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004699 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004700 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004701 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004702
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004703 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004704 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4705 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004706 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004707
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004708 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004709 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004710 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004711
4712 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004713 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4714 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004715 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004716 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004717 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004718 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4719 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4720 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4721 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4722 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4723 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004724 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004725 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004726 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004727 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004728
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004729 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004730 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004731 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004732 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004733
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004734 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4735 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4736 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4737 // warning can be disabled.
4738 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4739 return ConvTy;
4740 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4741 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004742
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004743 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4744 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4745 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4746 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4747 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4748 do {
4749 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4750 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004751
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004752 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4753 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4754 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004755
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004756 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004757 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004758 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004759
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004760 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004761 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004762 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004763 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004764}
4765
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004766/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4767/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4768/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4769// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004770Sema::AssignConvertType
4771Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004772 QualType rhsType) {
4773 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004774
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004775 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004776 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4777 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004778
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004779 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4780 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4781 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004782
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004783 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004784
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004785 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004786 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004787 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004788
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004789 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4790 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4791 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4792 }
4793 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004794 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004795 return ConvTy;
4796}
4797
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004798/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4799/// for assignment compatibility.
4800Sema::AssignConvertType
4801Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004802 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4803 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004804 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4805 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004806 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004807 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004808 }
4809 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4810 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004811 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4812 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004813 return IncompatiblePointer;
4814 return Compatible;
4815 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004816 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004817 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004818 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004819 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4820 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4821 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4822 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4823 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4824 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004825
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004826 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4827 return Compatible;
4828 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4829 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004830 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004831}
4832
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004833/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4834/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004835/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4836///
4837/// int a, *pint;
4838/// short *pshort;
4839/// struct foo *pfoo;
4840///
4841/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4842/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4843/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4844/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4845///
4846/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004847/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004848///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004849Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004850Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004851 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4852 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004853 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4854 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004855
4856 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004857 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004858
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004859 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4860 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4861 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4862 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4863 return Compatible;
4864 }
4865
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004866 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4867 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4868 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4869 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4870 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4871 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4872 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004873 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004874 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004875 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004876 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004877 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004878 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4879 // to the same ExtVector type.
4880 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4881 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4882 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004883 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004884 return Compatible;
4885 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004886
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004887 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004888 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4889 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4890 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4891 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4892 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4893 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004894 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004895
4896 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4897 // vector type and vice versa
4898 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4899 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004900 }
4901 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004902 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004903
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004904 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4905 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004906 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004907
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004908 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004909 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004910 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004911
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004912 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004913 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004914
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004915 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004916 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004917 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4918 return Compatible;
4919 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004920 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004921 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4922 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004923 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004924
4925 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004926 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004927 return Compatible;
4928 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004929 return Incompatible;
4930 }
4931
4932 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4933 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004934 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004935
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004936 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004937 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004938 return Compatible;
4939
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004940 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4941 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004942
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004943 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004944 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004945 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004946 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004947 return Incompatible;
4948 }
4949
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004950 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4951 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4952 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004953
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004954 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004955 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004956 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4957 return Compatible;
4958 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004959 }
4960 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004961 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004962 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004963 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004964 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4965 return Compatible;
4966 }
4967 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4968 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4969 return Compatible;
4970 return Incompatible;
4971 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004972 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004973 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004974 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4975 return Compatible;
4976
4977 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004978 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004979
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004980 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004981 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004982
4983 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004984 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004985 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004986 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004987 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004988 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4989 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4990 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4991 return Compatible;
4992
4993 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4994 return PointerToInt;
4995
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004996 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004997 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004998 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4999 return Compatible;
5000 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005001 }
5002 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005003 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005004 return Compatible;
5005 return Incompatible;
5006 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005007
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005008 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005009 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005010 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005011 }
5012 return Incompatible;
5013}
5014
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005015/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
5016/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005017static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005018 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
5019 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
5020 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00005021 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00005022 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005023 SourceLocation());
5024 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
5025 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
5026
5027 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
5028 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005029 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00005030 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005031 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005032}
5033
5034Sema::AssignConvertType
5035Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
5036 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
5037
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005038 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005039 // transparent_union GCC extension.
5040 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00005041 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005042 return Incompatible;
5043
5044 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
5045 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
5046 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
5047 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00005048 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
5049 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005050 it != itend; ++it) {
5051 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
5052 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
5053 // 1) void pointer
5054 // 2) null pointer constant
5055 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005056 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005057 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005058 InitField = *it;
5059 break;
5060 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005061
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005062 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005063 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005064 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005065 InitField = *it;
5066 break;
5067 }
5068 }
5069
5070 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
5071 == Compatible) {
Daniel Dunbar41e11a92010-09-17 23:21:43 +00005072 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005073 InitField = *it;
5074 break;
5075 }
5076 }
5077
5078 if (!InitField)
5079 return Incompatible;
5080
5081 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5082 return Compatible;
5083}
5084
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005085Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005086Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005087 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5088 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5089 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5090 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5091 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005092 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005093 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005094 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005095 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005096 }
5097
5098 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5099 // structures.
5100 }
5101
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005102 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5103 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005104 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5105 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005106 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005107 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005108 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005109 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005110 return Compatible;
5111 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005112
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005113 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005114 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005115 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyc133e9e2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005116 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005117 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005118 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005119 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005120 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005121
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005122 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5123 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005124
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005125 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5126 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005127 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5128 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5129 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5130 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005131 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005132 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005133 CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005134 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005135}
5136
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005137QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005138 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005139 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005140 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005141 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005142}
5143
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005144QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005145 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005146 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005147 QualType lhsType =
5148 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5149 QualType rhsType =
5150 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005151
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005152 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005153 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005154 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005155
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005156 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5157 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005158 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005159 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005160 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005161 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005162 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005163 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005164 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005165 return lhsType;
5166 }
5167
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005168 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005169 return rhsType;
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005170 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5171 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5172 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5173 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5174 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5175 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005176 }
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005177 }
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005178 }
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005179 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005180
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005181 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5182 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5183 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005184 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005185 return rhsType;
5186 }
5187
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005188 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5189 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5190 bool swapped = false;
5191 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5192 swapped = true;
5193 std::swap(rex, lex);
5194 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5195 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005196
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005197 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005198 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005199 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005200 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005201 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005202 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005203 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5204 return lhsType;
5205 }
5206 }
5207 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5208 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5209 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005210 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005211 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5212 return lhsType;
5213 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005214 }
5215 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005216
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005217 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005218 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005219 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005220 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005221 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005222}
5223
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005224QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5225 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005226 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005227 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005228
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005229 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005230
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005231 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5232 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5233 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005234
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005235 // Check for division by zero.
5236 if (isDiv &&
5237 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005238 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005239 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005240
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005241 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005242}
5243
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005244QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005245 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005246 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005247 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5248 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005249 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5250 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5251 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005252
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005253 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005254
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005255 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5256 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005257
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005258 // Check for remainder by zero.
5259 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005260 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5261 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005262
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005263 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005264}
5265
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005266QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005267 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005268 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5269 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5270 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5271 return compType;
5272 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005273
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005274 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005275
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005276 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005277 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5278 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5279 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005280 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005281 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005282
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005283 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5284 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005285 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005286 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5287
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005288 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005289
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005290 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005291 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005292
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005293 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5294 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005295 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5296 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005297 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005298 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005299 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005300
5301 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5302 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5303 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005304 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005305 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5306 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5307 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5308 return QualType();
5309 }
5310
5311 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5312 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5313 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005314 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005315 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005316 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005317 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005318 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5319 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005320 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5321 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005322 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005323 return QualType();
5324 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005325 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005326 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005327 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5328 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5329 return QualType();
5330 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005331
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005332 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005333 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5334 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5335 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5336 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5337 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005338 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005339 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5340 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005341 return PExp->getType();
5342 }
5343 }
5344
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005345 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005346}
5347
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005348// C99 6.5.6
5349QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005350 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5351 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5352 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5353 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5354 return compType;
5355 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005356
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005357 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005358
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005359 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005360
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005361 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005362 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5363 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005364 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005365 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005366 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005367
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005368 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005369 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005370 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005371
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005372 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005373
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005374 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5375 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5376 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5377 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5378 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5379 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5380 return QualType();
5381 }
5382
5383 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5384 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5385 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5386 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5387 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005388 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005389 return QualType();
5390 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005391
5392 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5393 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5394 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005395 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005396 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005397 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005398 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005399 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005400
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005401 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005402 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005403 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5404 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5405 return QualType();
5406 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005407
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005408 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005409 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5410 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5411 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5412 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5413 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5414 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005415 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005416 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5417
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005418 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005419 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005420 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005421
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005422 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005423 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005424 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005425
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005426 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5427 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5428 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5429 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5430 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5431 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5432 return QualType();
5433 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005434
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005435 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5436 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5437 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5438 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005439 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005440 return QualType();
5441 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005442
5443 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5444 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5445 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5446 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5447 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005448 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5449 << rex->getSourceRange()
5450 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005451 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005452
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005453 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5454 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5455 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5456 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5457 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5458 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5459 return QualType();
5460 }
5461 } else {
5462 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5463 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5464 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5465 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5466 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5467 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5468 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5469 return QualType();
5470 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005471 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005472
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005473 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5474 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5475 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5476 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5477 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005478 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005479 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005480
5481 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005482 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5483 }
5484 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005485
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005486 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005487}
5488
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005489static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
5490 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
5491 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
5492 return false;
5493}
5494
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005495// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005496QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005497 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005498 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005499 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5500 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005501 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005502
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005503 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
5504 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
5505 if (isScopedEnumerationType(lex->getType()) ||
5506 isScopedEnumerationType(rex->getType())) {
5507 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5508 }
5509
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005510 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5511 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5512 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5513
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005514 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5515 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005516 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5517 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5518 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5519 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5520 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005521 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005522 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005523 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005524
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005525 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005526
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005527 // Sanity-check shift operands
5528 llvm::APSInt Right;
5529 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005530 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5531 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005532 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005533 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5534 else {
5535 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5536 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5537 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5538 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5539 }
5540 }
5541
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005542 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005543 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005544}
5545
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005546static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5547 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5548 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5549 return true;
5550 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5551 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5552 }
5553 return false;
5554}
5555
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005556// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005557QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005558 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005559 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005560
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005561 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005562 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005563 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005564
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005565 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5566 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005567
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005568 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005569 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
5570 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
5571 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005572 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5573 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5574 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005575 //
5576 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5577 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5578 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5579 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5580 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5581 // result.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005582 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5583 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005584 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005585 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005586 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005587 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005588 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5589 << 0 // self-
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005590 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5591 || Opc == BO_LE
5592 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005593 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5594 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5595 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5596 // what is it always going to eval to?
5597 char always_evals_to;
5598 switch(Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005599 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005600 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5601 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005602 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005603 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5604 break;
5605 default:
5606 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5607 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5608 break;
5609 }
5610 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5611 << 1 // array
5612 << always_evals_to);
5613 }
5614 }
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005615 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005616
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005617 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5618 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5619 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5620 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005621
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005622 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5623 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005624 Expr *literalString = 0;
5625 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005626 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005627 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005628 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005629 literalString = lex;
5630 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005631 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5632 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005633 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005634 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005635 literalString = rex;
5636 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5637 }
5638
5639 if (literalString) {
5640 std::string resultComparison;
5641 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005642 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5643 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5644 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5645 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5646 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5647 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005648 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5649 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005650
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005651 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5652 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5653 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005654 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005655 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005656 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005657
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005658 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5659 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5660 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5661 else {
5662 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5663 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5664 }
5665
5666 lType = lex->getType();
5667 rType = rex->getType();
5668
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005669 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005670 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005671
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005672 if (isRelational) {
5673 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005674 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005675 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005676 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005677 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005678 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005679
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005680 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005681 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005682 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005683
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005684 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005685 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005686 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005687 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005688
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005689 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5690 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005691 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005692 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005693 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005694 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005695 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005696
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005697 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005698 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5699 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005700 if (!isRelational &&
5701 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5702 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5703 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005704 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5705 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005706 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5707 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005708 Diag(Loc,
5709 isSFINAEContext()?
5710 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5711 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005712 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005713
5714 if (isSFINAEContext())
5715 return QualType();
5716
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005717 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005718 return ResultTy;
5719 }
5720 }
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005721 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5722 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5723 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5724 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5725 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5726 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005727 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005728 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005729 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005730 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005731 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005732 if (T.isNull()) {
5733 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5734 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5735 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005736 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005737 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005738 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005739 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005740 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005741 }
5742
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005743 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5744 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005745 return ResultTy;
5746 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005747 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5748 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5749 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5750 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5751 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5752 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5753 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5754 }
5755 } else if (!isRelational &&
5756 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5757 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5758 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5759 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5760 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5761 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5762 }
5763 } else {
5764 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005765 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005766 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005767 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005768 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005769 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005770 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005771 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005772
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005773 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005774 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005775 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005776 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005777 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5778 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005779 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5780 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005781 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5782 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005783 return ResultTy;
5784 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005785 if (LHSIsNull &&
5786 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5787 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005788 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5789 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005790 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5791 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005792 return ResultTy;
5793 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005794
5795 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005796 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005797 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5798 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005799 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5800 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5801 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5802 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5803 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5804 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5805 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5806 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005807 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005808 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005809 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005810 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005811 if (T.isNull()) {
5812 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005813 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005814 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005815 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005816 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005817 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005818 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005819 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005820 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005821
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005822 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5823 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005824 return ResultTy;
5825 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005826
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005827 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005828 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5829 return ResultTy;
5830 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005831
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005832 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005833 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005834 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5835 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005836
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005837 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005838 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005839 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005840 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005841 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005842 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005843 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005844 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005845 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005846 if (!isRelational
5847 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5848 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005849 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005850 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005851 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005852 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005853 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5854 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5855 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005856 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005857 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005858 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005859 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005860
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005861 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005862 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005863 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5864 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005865 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005866 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005867 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005868 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005869
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005870 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5871 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005872 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005873 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005874 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005875 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005876 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005877 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005878 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005879 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005880 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5881 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005882 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005883 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005884 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005885 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005886 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5887 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005888 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005889 bool isError = false;
5890 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5891 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5892 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005893 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005894 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005895 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005896 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5897 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5898 isError = true;
5899 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005900 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005901
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005902 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005903 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005904 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005905 if (isError)
5906 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005907 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005908
5909 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005910 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005911 else
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005912 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005913 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005914 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005915
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005916 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005917 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5918 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005919 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005920 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005921 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005922 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5923 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005924 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005925 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005926 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005927 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005928}
5929
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005930/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005931/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005932/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5933/// types.
5934QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005935 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005936 bool isRelational) {
5937 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5938 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005939 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005940 if (vType.isNull())
5941 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005942
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005943 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5944 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005945
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005946 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5947 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5948 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005949 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005950 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5951 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5952 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005953 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5954 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5955 << 0 // self-
5956 << 2 // "a constant"
5957 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005958 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005959
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005960 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005961 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5962 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005963 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005964 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005965
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005966 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5967 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5968 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005969 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005970 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005971
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005972 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005973 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005974 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005975 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005976 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005977 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5978
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005979 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005980 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005981 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5982}
5983
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005984inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005985 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005986 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5987 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5988 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5989 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5990
5991 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5992 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005993
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005994 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005995
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005996 if (lex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
5997 rex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005998 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005999 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006000}
6001
6002inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006003 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
6004
6005 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
6006 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
6007 // is a constant.
6008 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman787b0942010-07-27 19:14:53 +00006009 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattner23ef3e42010-07-15 00:26:43 +00006010 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006011 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
6012 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
6013 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
6014 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
6015 Expr::EvalResult Result;
6016 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
6017 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
6018 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
6019 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006020 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
6021 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006022 }
6023 }
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006024
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006025 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6026 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
6027 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006028
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006029 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
6030 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006031
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006032 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00006033 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006034
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006035 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
6036 // non-overloadable operands.
6037
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006038 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
6039 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006040 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
6041 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
6042 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006043 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006044
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006045 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
6046 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
6047 // The result is a bool.
6048 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006049}
6050
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006051/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
6052/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
6053/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
6054///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006055static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006056 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
6057 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
6058 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00006059 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->isSuperReceiver() ?
6060 PropExpr->getSuperType() :
6061 PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
6062
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006063 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006064 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
6065 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
6066 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
6067 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006068 }
6069 }
6070 return false;
6071}
6072
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006073/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
6074/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
6075static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006076 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006077 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006078 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006079 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
6080 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006081 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
6082 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006083
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006084 unsigned Diag = 0;
6085 bool NeedType = false;
6086 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006087 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006088 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006089 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6090 NeedType = true;
6091 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006092 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006093 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6094 NeedType = true;
6095 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006096 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006097 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6098 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006099 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6100 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006101 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006102 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6103 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006104 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6105 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006106 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6107 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006108 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006109 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006110 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006111 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006112 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6113 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006114 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006115 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6116 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006117 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6118 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6119 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006120 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6121 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6122 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006123 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6124 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6125 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006126 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006127
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006128 SourceRange Assign;
6129 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6130 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006131 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006132 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006133 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006134 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006135 return true;
6136}
6137
6138
6139
6140// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006141QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6142 SourceLocation Loc,
6143 QualType CompoundType) {
6144 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6145 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006146 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006147
6148 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6149 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006150 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006151 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006152 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006153 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006154 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006155 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006156 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6157 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6158 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006159 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006160 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006161 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006162 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006163
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006164 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6165 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6166 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006167 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006168 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6169 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6170 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006171 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6172 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006173 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006174 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006175 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6176 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6177 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006178 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6179 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006180 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006181 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006182 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006183 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006184 }
6185 } else {
6186 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006187 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006188 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006189
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006190 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006191 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006192 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006193
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006194
6195 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6196 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6197 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6198 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6199 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6200 // check.
6201 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006202 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006203 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6204 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6205 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6206 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6207 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6208 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6209 }
6210
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006211 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6212 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006213 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006214 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6215 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006216 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006217 // operand.
John McCall2bf6f492010-10-12 02:19:57 +00006218 return (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6219 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006220}
6221
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006222// C99 6.5.17
6223QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006224 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6225
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006226 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
6227 // operands, but not unary promotions.
6228 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6229 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6230 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS);
6231 if (!LHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6232 RequireCompleteType(Loc, LHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006233
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006234 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
6235 if (!RHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6236 RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
6237 }
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006238
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006239 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006240}
6241
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006242/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6243/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006244QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006245 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006246 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6247 return Context.DependentTy;
6248
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006249 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6250 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006251
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006252 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6253 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6254 if (!isInc) {
6255 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6256 return QualType();
6257 }
6258 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6259 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6260 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006261 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006262 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6263 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006264
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006265 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006266 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006267 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6268 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6269 << Op->getSourceRange();
6270 return QualType();
6271 }
6272
6273 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006274 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006275 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006276 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6277 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6278 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6279 return QualType();
6280 }
6281
6282 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006283 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006284 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006285 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006286 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006287 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006288 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006289 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006290 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006291 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6292 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6293 return QualType();
6294 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006295 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006296 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6297 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006298 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006299 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6300 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6301 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6302 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc, isInc, isPrefix);
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006303 } else {
6304 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006305 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006306 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006307 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006308 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006309 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006310 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006311 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006312 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6313 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6314 // operand.
6315 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6316 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006317}
6318
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006319void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6320 bool copyInit = false;
6321 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6322 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6323 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6324 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6325 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6326 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6327 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6328 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6329 }
6330 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6331 }
6332 else
6333 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6334 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6335 if (copyInit) {
6336 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006337 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006338 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6339 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6340 Owned(Arg));
6341 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006342 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006343 }
6344}
6345
6346
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006347/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006348/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006349/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6350/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6351/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6352/// - &(x) => x
6353/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6354/// - &s.xx => s
6355/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6356/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6357/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6358/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006359static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006360 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006361 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006362 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006363 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006364 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6365 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6366 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006367 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006368 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006369 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006370 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006371 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006372 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6373 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006374 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6375 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6376 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6377 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6378 }
6379 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006380 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006381 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6382 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006383
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006384 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006385 case UO_Real:
6386 case UO_Imag:
6387 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006388 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6389 default:
6390 return 0;
6391 }
6392 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006393 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006394 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006395 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006396 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6397 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006398 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006399 default:
6400 return 0;
6401 }
6402}
6403
6404/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006405/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006406/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006407/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006408/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006409/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006410/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006411QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6412 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006413 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006414 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6415 return Context.OverloadTy;
6416
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006417 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp, OpLoc);
6418 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6419 OrigOp = PR.take();
6420
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006421 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6422 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006423
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006424 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6425 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6426 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006427 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006428 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6429 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6430 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6431 }
6432 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6433 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6434 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006435 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006436 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006437
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006438 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006439 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6440 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6441 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6442 if (isSFINAEContext())
6443 return QualType();
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006444 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006445 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006446 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6447 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6448 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6449
6450 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6451 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6452 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6453 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6454 return QualType();
6455 }
6456 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6457 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6458
6459 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6460 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6461 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6462 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6463
6464 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6465 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6466 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6467 << op->getSourceRange();
6468 }
6469
6470 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6471 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6472 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006473 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006474 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006475 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006476 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006477 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6478 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006479 return QualType();
6480 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006481 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006482 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6483 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6484 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006485 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006486 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006487 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006488 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006489 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006490 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006491 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6492 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6493 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6494 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6495 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006496 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6497 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006498 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6499 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006500 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006501 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006502 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6503 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006504 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6505 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCalld931b082010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006506 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006507 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006508 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6509 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006510 return QualType();
6511 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006512 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006513 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006514 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006515 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006516 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6517 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006518 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006519 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006520 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6521 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006522 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006523 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6524 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6525 return QualType();
6526 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006527
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006528 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6529 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006530 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006531 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006532 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006533 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006534 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006535
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006536 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6537 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6538 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6539 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6540 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6541 }
6542
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006543 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor8f70ddb2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006544 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6545 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006546 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6547}
6548
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006549/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006550QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006551 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6552 return Context.DependentTy;
6553
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006554 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006555 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6556 QualType Result;
6557
6558 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6559 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6560 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6561 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6562 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6563 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6564 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6565 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6566 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006567 else {
6568 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6569 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6570 if (PR.take() != Op) return CheckIndirectionOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc);
6571 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006572
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006573 if (Result.isNull()) {
6574 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6575 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6576 return QualType();
6577 }
6578
6579 return Result;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006580}
6581
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006582static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006583 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006584 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006585 switch (Kind) {
6586 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006587 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6588 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6589 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6590 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6591 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6592 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6593 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6594 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6595 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6596 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6597 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6598 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6599 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6600 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6601 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6602 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6603 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6604 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6605 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6606 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6607 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6608 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6609 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6610 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6611 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6612 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6613 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6614 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6615 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6616 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6617 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6618 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006619 }
6620 return Opc;
6621}
6622
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006623static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006624 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006625 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006626 switch (Kind) {
6627 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006628 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6629 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6630 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6631 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6632 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6633 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6634 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6635 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6636 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6637 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6638 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006639 }
6640 return Opc;
6641}
6642
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006643/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6644/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6645/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006646ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006647 unsigned Op,
6648 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006649 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006650 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006651 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6652 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6653 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006654
6655 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006656 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006657 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6658 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006659 case BO_PtrMemD:
6660 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006661 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006662 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006663 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006664 case BO_Mul:
6665 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006666 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006667 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006668 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006669 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006670 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6671 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006672 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006673 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6674 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006675 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006676 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6677 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006678 case BO_Shl:
6679 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006680 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6681 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006682 case BO_LE:
6683 case BO_LT:
6684 case BO_GE:
6685 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006686 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006687 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006688 case BO_EQ:
6689 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006690 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006691 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006692 case BO_And:
6693 case BO_Xor:
6694 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006695 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6696 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006697 case BO_LAnd:
6698 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006699 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006700 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006701 case BO_MulAssign:
6702 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006703 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006704 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006705 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6706 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6707 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006708 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006709 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006710 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6711 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6712 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6713 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006714 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006715 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006716 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6717 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6718 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006719 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006720 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006721 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6722 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6723 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006724 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006725 case BO_ShlAssign:
6726 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006727 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6728 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6729 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6730 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006731 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006732 case BO_AndAssign:
6733 case BO_XorAssign:
6734 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006735 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6736 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6737 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6738 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006739 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006740 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006741 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6742 break;
6743 }
6744 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006745 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006746 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006747 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006748 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6749 << ResultTy;
6750 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006751 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006752 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6753 else
6754 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006755 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6756 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006757}
6758
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006759/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6760/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006761static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6762 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006763 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6764 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6765 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006766 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006767 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6768
6769 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6770 return;
6771
6772 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6773 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6774 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006775 return;
6776 }
6777
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006778 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6779 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006780 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006781
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006782 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006783 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006784
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006785 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6786 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6787 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6788 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006789 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006790 return;
6791 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006792
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006793 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006794 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6795 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006796}
6797
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006798/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6799/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6800/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6801/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006802static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006803 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006804 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6805 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6806 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6807 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006808 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006809 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006810 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6811
6812 // Subs are not binary operators.
6813 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6814 return;
6815
6816 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6817 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006818 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6819 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006820 return;
6821
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006822 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006823 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006824 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006825 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6826 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006827 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006828 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006829 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6830 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6831 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6832 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006833 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006834 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006835 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006836 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6837 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006838 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006839 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006840 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6841 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6842 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6843 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006844}
6845
6846/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6847/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6848/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006849static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006850 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006851 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006852 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6853}
6854
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006855// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006856ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006857 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6858 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6859 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006860 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6861 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006862
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006863 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6864 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6865
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006866 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6867}
6868
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006869ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006870 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6871 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006872 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006873 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
6874 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianeb17e8b2010-09-17 20:45:45 +00006875 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006876 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006877 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6878 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6879 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6880 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6881 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006882 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006883 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006884 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6885 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6886 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006887
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006888 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6889 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006890 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006891 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006892
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006893 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006894 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006895}
6896
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006897ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006898 unsigned OpcIn,
6899 Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006900 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006901
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006902 QualType resultType;
6903 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006904 case UO_PreInc:
6905 case UO_PreDec:
6906 case UO_PostInc:
6907 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006908 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006909 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6910 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6911 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6912 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006913 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006914 case UO_AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006915 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6916 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006917 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006918 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006919 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6920 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006921 case UO_Plus:
6922 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006923 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6924 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006925 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6926 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006927 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6928 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006929 break;
6930 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6931 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6932 break;
6933 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006934 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006935 resultType->isPointerType())
6936 break;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006937 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6938 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6939 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6940 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6941 }
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006942
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006943 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6944 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006945 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006946 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6947 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006948 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6949 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006950 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6951 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6952 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006953 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006954 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006955 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
6956 break;
6957 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6958 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6959 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6960 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6961 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006962 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6963 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006964 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006965 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006966 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006967 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006968 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006969 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006970 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6971 break;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006972 if (resultType->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6973 // ok, fallthrough
6974 } else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6975 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6976 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6977 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6978 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006979 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6980 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006981 }
Douglas Gregorea844f32010-09-20 17:13:33 +00006982
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006983 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006984 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6985 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006986 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006987 case UO_Real:
6988 case UO_Imag:
6989 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006990 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006991 case UO_Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006992 resultType = Input->getType();
6993 break;
6994 }
6995 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006996 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006997
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006998 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006999}
7000
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007001ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007002 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
7003 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00007004 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman957c0942010-09-05 23:15:52 +00007005 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007006 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
7007 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
7008 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
7009 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007010 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007011 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007012 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
7013 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
7014 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007015
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007016 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007017 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007018
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007019 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007020}
7021
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007022// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007023ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007024 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
7025 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007026}
7027
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00007028/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007029ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007030 SourceLocation LabLoc,
7031 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007032 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007033 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007034
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00007035 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
7036 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00007037 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007038 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007039
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007040 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007041 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007042 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
7043 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007044}
7045
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007046ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007047Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007048 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007049 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
7050 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
7051
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00007052 bool isFileScope
7053 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00007054 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007055 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00007056
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007057 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
7058 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
7059 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007060
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007061 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
7062 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
7063 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007064 bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007065 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
7066 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007067 LabelStmt *LastLabelStmt = 0;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007068 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007069 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt)) {
7070 LastLabelStmt = Label;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007071 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007072 }
7073 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt)) {
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007074 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian500b7822010-10-27 20:10:28 +00007075 if (Ty->isArrayType())
7076 Ty = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007077 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && !LastExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
7078 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
7079 InitializedEntity::InitializeResult(LPLoc,
7080 Ty,
7081 false),
7082 SourceLocation(),
7083 Owned(LastExpr));
7084 if (Res.isInvalid())
7085 return ExprError();
7086 if ((LastExpr = Res.takeAs<Expr>())) {
7087 if (!LastLabelStmt)
7088 Compound->setLastStmt(LastExpr);
7089 else
7090 LastLabelStmt->setSubStmt(LastExpr);
7091 StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true;
7092 }
7093 }
7094 }
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007095 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007096
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007097 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
7098 // expressions are not lvalues.
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007099 Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc);
7100 if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp)
7101 return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr);
7102 return Owned(ResStmtExpr);
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007103}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007104
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007105ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007106 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7107 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7108 unsigned NumComponents,
7109 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007110 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007111 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00007112 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007113
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007114 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
7115 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
7116 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007117 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007118 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7119 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
7120
7121 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
7122 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
7123 if (!Dependent
7124 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
7125 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
7126 << TypeRange))
7127 return ExprError();
7128
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007129 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
7130 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00007131 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
7132 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007133 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00007134 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
7135 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007136
7137 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
7138 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
7139 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
7140 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
7141 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
7142 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7143 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7144 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7145 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7146 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7147 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7148 if(!AT)
7149 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7150 << CurrentType);
7151 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7152 } else
7153 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7154
7155 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7156 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7157 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7158 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7159 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7160 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7161 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7162 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7163
7164 // Record this array index.
7165 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7166 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7167 continue;
7168 }
7169
7170 // Offset of a field.
7171 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7172 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7173 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7174 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7175 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7176 continue;
7177 }
7178
7179 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7180 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7181 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7182 return ExprError();
7183
7184 // Look for the designated field.
7185 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7186 if (!RC)
7187 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7188 << CurrentType);
7189 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7190
7191 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7192 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7193 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7194 // (clause 9).
7195 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7196 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7197 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7198 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7199 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7200 << CurrentType))
7201 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7202 }
7203
7204 // Look for the field.
7205 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7206 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7207 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7208 if (!MemberDecl)
7209 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7210 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7211 OC.LocEnd));
7212
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007213 // C99 7.17p3:
7214 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7215 //
7216 // We diagnose this as an error.
7217 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7218 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7219 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7220 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7221 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7222 return ExprError();
7223 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007224
7225 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7226 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7227 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7228 do {
7229 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7230 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7231 }
7232
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007233 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7234 // the base class indirections.
7235 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7236 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007237 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007238 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7239 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7240 B != BEnd; ++B)
7241 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7242 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007243
7244 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007245 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7246 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7247 unsigned n = Path.size();
7248 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7249 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7250 } else {
7251 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7252 }
7253 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7254 }
7255
7256 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7257 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7258 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7259}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007260
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007261ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007262 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7263 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
7264 ParsedType argty,
7265 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7266 unsigned NumComponents,
7267 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7268
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007269 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7270 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7271 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7272 return ExprError();
7273
Eli Friedman5a15dc12010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007274 if (!ArgTInfo)
7275 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7276
7277 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7278 RPLoc);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007279}
7280
7281
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007282ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007283 ParsedType arg1, ParsedType arg2,
7284 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007285 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7286 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7287 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7288 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007289
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007290 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007291
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007292 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7293}
7294
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007295ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007296Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7297 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7298 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7299 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007300 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7301 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7302 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7303 return ExprError();
7304 }
7305
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007306 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007307 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007308}
7309
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007310
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007311ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007312 Expr *CondExpr,
7313 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
7314 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007315 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7316
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007317 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007318 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007319 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007320 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007321 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007322 } else {
7323 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7324 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7325 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7326 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007327 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7328 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7329 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007330
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007331 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7332 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007333 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7334 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007335 }
7336
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007337 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007338 resType, RPLoc,
7339 resType->isDependentType(),
7340 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007341}
7342
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007343//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7344// Clang Extensions.
7345//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7346
7347/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007348void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007349 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7350 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7351 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007352 if (BlockScope)
7353 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7354 else
7355 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007356}
7357
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007358void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007359 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007360 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007361
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007362 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007363 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007364 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007365
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007366 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007367 QualType RetTy;
7368 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007369 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007370 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007371 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007372 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7373 } else {
7374 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007375 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007376 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007377
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007378 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007379
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007380 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7381 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7382 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007383 return;
7384 }
7385
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007386 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7387 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7388 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7389 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7390 return;
7391 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007392
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007393 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007394 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7395 // ^ * { ... }
7396 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007397 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7398 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007399
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007400 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007401 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007402 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7403 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7404 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7405 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007406 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7407 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7408 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7409 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7410 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007411 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007412 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007413
7414 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7415 // ^ fntype { ... }
7416 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7417 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7418 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7419 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7420 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7421 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7422 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007423 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007424 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007425 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007426
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007427 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7428 if (!Params.empty())
7429 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007430
7431 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007432 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007433
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007434 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007435 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7436 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7437 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7438 }
7439
7440 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7441 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007442 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007443 return;
7444
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007445 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7446 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7447
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007448 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007449 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7450 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7451
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007452 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007453 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7454 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7455 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7456
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007457 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007458 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007459 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007460}
7461
7462/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7463/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7464void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007465 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007466 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007467 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007468 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007469}
7470
7471/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7472/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007473ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007474 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007475 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7476 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7477 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007478
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007479 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007480
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007481 PopDeclContext();
7482
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007483 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007484 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7485 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007486
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007487 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007488 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007489
7490 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7491 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7492 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7493
7494 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7495 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7496
7497 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7498 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7499 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7500 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7501
7502 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7503 // preserve its sugar structure.
7504 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7505 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7506 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7507
7508 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7509 } else {
7510 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7511 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7512 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7513 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7514 FPT->isVariadic(),
7515 /*quals*/ 0,
7516 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7517 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7518 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7519 FPT->exception_begin(),
7520 Ext);
7521 }
7522
7523 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7524 } else {
7525 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7526 false, false, 0, 0,
7527 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7528 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007529
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007530 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007531 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7532 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007533 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007534
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007535 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007536 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007537 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007538
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007539 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007540
7541 bool Good = true;
7542 // Check goto/label use.
7543 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7544 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7545 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7546
7547 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7548 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007549 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
7550 if (!L->isUsed())
7551 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007552 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007553 }
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007554
7555 // Emit error.
7556 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7557 Good = false;
7558 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007559 if (!Good) {
7560 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007561 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007562 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007563
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007564 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7565 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7566
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007567 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007568 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7569 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007570 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007571
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007572 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007573 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007574}
7575
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007576ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007577 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007578 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007579 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7580 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007581 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007582}
7583
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007584ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007585 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007586 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007587 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007588
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007589 // Get the va_list type
7590 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007591 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7592 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7593 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7594 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007595 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007596 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7597 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7598 } else {
7599 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7600 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007601 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007602 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007603 return ExprError();
7604 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007605
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007606 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7607 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007608 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7609 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007610 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007611 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007612
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007613 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007614 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007615
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007616 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7617 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007618}
7619
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007620ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007621 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7622 // pointers on the target.
7623 QualType Ty;
7624 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7625 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7626 else
7627 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7628
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007629 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007630}
7631
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007632static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007633 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007634 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7635 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007636
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007637 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7638 if (!PT)
7639 return;
7640
7641 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7642 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7643 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7644 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7645 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7646 return;
7647 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007648
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007649 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7650 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7651 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7652 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007653
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007654 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007655}
7656
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007657bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7658 SourceLocation Loc,
7659 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007660 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7661 bool *Complained) {
7662 if (Complained)
7663 *Complained = false;
7664
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007665 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7666 bool isInvalid = false;
7667 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007668 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007669
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007670 switch (ConvTy) {
7671 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7672 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007673 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007674 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7675 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007676 case IntToPointer:
7677 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7678 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007679 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007680 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007681 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7682 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007683 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7684 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7685 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007686 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7687 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7688 break;
7689 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007690 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7691 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7692 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7693 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7694 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7695 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7696 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7697 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7698 // C++ semantics.
7699 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7700 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7701 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007702 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7703 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007704 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007705 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007706 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007707 case IntToBlockPointer:
7708 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7709 break;
7710 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007711 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007712 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007713 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007714 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007715 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7716 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7717 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007718 case IncompatibleVectors:
7719 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7720 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007721 case Incompatible:
7722 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7723 isInvalid = true;
7724 break;
7725 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007726
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007727 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7728 switch (Action) {
7729 case AA_Assigning:
7730 case AA_Initializing:
7731 // The destination type comes first.
7732 FirstType = DstType;
7733 SecondType = SrcType;
7734 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007735
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007736 case AA_Returning:
7737 case AA_Passing:
7738 case AA_Converting:
7739 case AA_Sending:
7740 case AA_Casting:
7741 // The source type comes first.
7742 FirstType = SrcType;
7743 SecondType = DstType;
7744 break;
7745 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007746
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007747 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007748 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007749 if (Complained)
7750 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007751 return isInvalid;
7752}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007753
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007754bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007755 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7756 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7757 if (Result)
7758 *Result = ICEResult;
7759 return false;
7760 }
7761
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007762 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7763
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007764 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007765 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7766 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7767
7768 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7769 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7770 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7771 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7772 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7773 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7774 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007775
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007776 return true;
7777 }
7778
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007779 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7780 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007781
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007782 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7783 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7784 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007785
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007786 if (Result)
7787 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7788 return false;
7789}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007790
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007791void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007792Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007793 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7794 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007795}
7796
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007797void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007798Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7799 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7800 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7801 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007802
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007803 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7804 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7805 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7806 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7807 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007808 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007809 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7810 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7811 I != IEnd; ++I)
7812 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7813 }
7814
7815 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7816 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7817 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7818 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7819 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7820 I != IEnd; ++I)
7821 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7822 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007823 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007824
7825 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7826 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7827 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7828 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007829 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007830 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7831 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7832 ExprTemporaries.end());
7833
7834 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7835 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007836}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007837
7838/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7839///
7840/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7841/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7842/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7843/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7844///
7845/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7846///
7847/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7848void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7849 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007850
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007851 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007852 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007853
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007854 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7855 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7856 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7857 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007858 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007859 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Anders Carlsson2127ecc2010-10-22 23:37:08 +00007860 D->setUsed();
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007861 return;
7862 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007863
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007864 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7865 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007866
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007867 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7868 // an instantiation.
7869 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7870 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007871
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007872 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007873 case Unevaluated:
7874 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7875 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007876
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007877 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7878 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7879 // "used"; handle this below.
7880 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007881
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007882 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7883 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7884 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7885 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007886 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007887 return;
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007888
7889 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
7890 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
7891 // containing expression is used.
7892 return;
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007893 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007894
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007895 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007896 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007897 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007898 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruth4e6fbce2010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007899 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7900 return;
7901 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7902 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007903 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007904 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007905 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007906 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7907 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007908
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007909 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007910 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007911 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007912 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007913 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7914 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007915 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7916 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7917 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007918 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007919 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007920 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7921 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007922 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007923 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007924 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007925 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007926 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007927 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7928 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7929 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7930 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7931 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007932 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007933 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007934 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007935 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007936 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7937 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7938 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007939 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007940 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007941 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7942 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007943
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007944 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7945 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7946 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7947 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7948 Loc));
7949 else
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007950 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007951 }
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007952 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
7953 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
7954 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greifbe9ebe32010-08-28 01:58:12 +00007955 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007956 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
7957 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007958
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007959 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidis58b52592010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007960
7961 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7962 if (CurContext != Function)
7963 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007964
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007965 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007966 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007967
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007968 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007969 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007970 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007971 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7972 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7973 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7974 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7975 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7976 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007977 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007978 }
7979 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007980
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007981 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007982
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007983 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007984 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007985 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007986}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007987
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007988namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007989 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007990 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007991 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007992 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7993 Sema &S;
7994 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007995
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007996 public:
7997 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007998
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007999 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008000
8001 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
8002 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008003 };
8004}
8005
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008006bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
8007 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008008 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
8009 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
8010 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008011
8012 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008013}
8014
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008015bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008016 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
8017 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
8018 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008019 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
8020 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008021 }
8022
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00008023 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008024}
8025
8026void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
8027 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008028 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008029}
8030
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008031namespace {
8032 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
8033 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8034 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
8035 Sema &S;
8036
8037 public:
8038 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
8039
8040 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
8041
8042 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
8043 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8044 }
8045
8046 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
8047 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008048 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008049 }
8050
8051 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
8052 if (E->getConstructor())
8053 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
8054 if (E->getOperatorNew())
8055 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
8056 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8057 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008058 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008059 }
8060
8061 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
8062 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8063 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00008064 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
8065 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
8066 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
8067 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
8068 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
8069 }
8070
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008071 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008072 }
8073
8074 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
8075 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008076 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008077 }
8078
8079 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
8080 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8081 }
Douglas Gregor102ff972010-10-19 17:17:35 +00008082
8083 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) {
8084 Visit(E->getExpr());
8085 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008086 };
8087}
8088
8089/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
8090/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8091void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
8092 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
8093}
8094
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008095/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
8096/// of the program being compiled.
8097///
8098/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008099/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008100/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
8101/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
8102/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
8103/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008104/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008105/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008106///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008107/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
8108/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
8109/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
8110/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008111bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008112 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
8113 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
8114 case Unevaluated:
8115 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
8116 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008117
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008118 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008119 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008120 Diag(Loc, PD);
8121 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008122
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008123 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
8124 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
8125 break;
8126 }
8127
8128 return false;
8129}
8130
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008131bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
8132 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
8133 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
8134 return false;
8135
8136 PartialDiagnostic Note =
8137 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
8138 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
8139 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008140
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008141 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008142 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008143 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
8144 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008145 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008146 << CE->getSourceRange(),
8147 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
8148 return true;
8149
8150 return false;
8151}
8152
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008153// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8154// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8155void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8156 SourceLocation Loc;
8157
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008158 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8159
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008160 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8161 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008162 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008163 return;
8164
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008165 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8166 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8167 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8168 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8169
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008170 // self = [<foo> init...]
8171 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8172 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8173 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8174
8175 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8176 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8177 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8178 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8179 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008180
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008181 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8182 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8183 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8184 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8185 return;
8186
8187 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8188 } else {
8189 // Not an assignment.
8190 return;
8191 }
8192
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008193 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008194 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008195
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008196 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008197 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008198 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008199 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8200 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8201 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008202}
8203
8204bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8205 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8206
8207 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008208 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008209
8210 QualType T = E->getType();
8211
8212 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8213 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8214 return true;
8215 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8216 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8217 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8218 return true;
8219 }
8220 }
8221
8222 return false;
8223}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008224
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008225ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8226 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008227 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008228 return ExprError();
8229
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008230 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008231 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008232
8233 return Owned(Sub);
8234}
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008235
8236/// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
8237/// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
8238ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8239 const BuiltinType *BT = E->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8240 if (!BT || !BT->isPlaceholderType()) return Owned(E);
8241
8242 // If this is overload, check for a single overload.
8243 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
8244 if (FunctionDecl *Specialization
8245 = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(E)) {
8246 // The access doesn't really matter in this case.
8247 DeclAccessPair Found = DeclAccessPair::make(Specialization,
8248 Specialization->getAccess());
8249 E = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, Found, Specialization);
8250 if (!E) return ExprError();
8251 return Owned(E);
8252 }
8253
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008254 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ovl_unresolvable) << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008255 return ExprError();
8256 }
8257
8258 // Otherwise it's a use of undeduced auto.
8259 assert(BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::UndeducedAuto);
8260
8261 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens());
8262 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
8263 << DRE->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
8264 return ExprError();
8265}